xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 730eeb17bbdd3c31f91e2a4fff35dd7e9c67d706)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228  *
229  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231  *
232  * @def: the channel definition
233  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242  */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246 
247 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248 
249 	bool radar_enabled;
250 
251 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253 
254 /**
255  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266  *      for changes/removal.)
267  */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275  *
276  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279  * done.
280  *
281  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285  */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295  *
296  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298  *
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300  *	also implies a change in the AID.
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324  *	changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329  *	context had been assigned.
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333  *	keep alive) changed.
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342  *	status changed.
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344  */
345 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
346 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
347 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
348 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
379 
380 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
381 };
382 
383 /*
384  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
385  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
386  * filtering will be disabled.
387  */
388 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
389 
390 /**
391  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
392  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
393  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
394  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
395  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
396  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
397  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
398  */
399 enum ieee80211_event_type {
400 	RSSI_EVENT,
401 	MLME_EVENT,
402 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
403 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
404 };
405 
406 /**
407  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
408  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
409  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
410  */
411 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
412 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
413 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
414 };
415 
416 /**
417  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
418  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
419  */
420 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
421 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
422 };
423 
424 /**
425  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
426  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
427  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
428  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
429  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
430  */
431 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
432 	AUTH_EVENT,
433 	ASSOC_EVENT,
434 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
435 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
436 };
437 
438 /**
439  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
440  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
441  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
442  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
443  */
444 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
445 	MLME_SUCCESS,
446 	MLME_DENIED,
447 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
448 };
449 
450 /**
451  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
452  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
453  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
454  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
455  */
456 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
457 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
458 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
459 	u16 reason;
460 };
461 
462 /**
463  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
464  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
465  * @tid: the tid
466  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
467  */
468 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
469 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
470 	u16 tid;
471 	u16 ssn;
472 };
473 
474 /**
475  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
476  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
477  * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
478  * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
479  * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
480  * @u:union holding the fields above
481  */
482 struct ieee80211_event {
483 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
484 	union {
485 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
486 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
487 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
488 	} u;
489 };
490 
491 /**
492  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
493  *
494  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
495  *
496  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
497  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
498  */
499 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
500 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
501 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
502 };
503 
504 /**
505  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
506  *
507  * @lci: LCI subelement content
508  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
509  * @lci_len: LCI data length
510  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
511  */
512 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
513 	const u8 *lci;
514 	const u8 *civicloc;
515 	size_t lci_len;
516 	size_t civicloc_len;
517 };
518 
519 /**
520  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
521  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
522  *
523  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
524  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
525  */
526 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
527 	u32 min_interval;
528 	u32 max_interval;
529 };
530 
531 /**
532  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
533  *
534  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
535  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
536  *
537  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
538  * @addr: (link) address used locally
539  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
540  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
541  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
542  * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
543  *	ACK, BACK or both
544  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
545  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
546  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
547  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
548  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
549  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
552  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
553  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
554  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
555  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
556  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
557  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
558  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
559  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
560  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
561  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
562  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
563  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
564  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
565  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
566  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
567  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
568  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
569  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
570  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
571  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
572  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
573  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
574  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
575  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
576  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
577  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
578  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
579  *	the current band.
580  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
581  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
582  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
583  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
584  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
585  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
586  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
587  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
588  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
589  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
590  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
591  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
592  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
593  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
594  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
595  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
596  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
597  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
598  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
599  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
600  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
601  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
602  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
603  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
604  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
605  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
606  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
607  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
608  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
609  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
610  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
611  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
612  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
613  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
614  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
615  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
616  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
617  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
618  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
619  *	station.
620  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
621  *	responder functionality.
622  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
623  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
624  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
625  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
626  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
627  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
628  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
629  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
630  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
631  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
632  *	connected to (STA)
633  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
634  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
635  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
636  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
637  *	interval.
638  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
639  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
640  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
641  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
642  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
643  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
644  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
645  * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
646  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
647  * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
648  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
649  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
650  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
651  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
652  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
653  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
654  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
655  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
656  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
657  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
658  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
659  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
660  *	beamformer
661  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
662  *	beamformee
663  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
664  *	beamformer
665  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
666  *	beamformee
667  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
668  *	beamformer
669  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
670  *	beamformee
671  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
672  *	beamformer
673  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
674  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
675  *	bandwidth
676  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
677  *	beamformer
678  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
679  *	beamformee
680  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
681  *	beamformer
682  */
683 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
684 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
685 
686 	const u8 *bssid;
687 	unsigned int link_id;
688 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
689 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
690 	bool uora_exists;
691 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
692 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
693 	bool he_support;
694 	bool twt_requester;
695 	bool twt_responder;
696 	bool twt_protected;
697 	bool twt_broadcast;
698 	/* erp related data */
699 	bool use_cts_prot;
700 	bool use_short_preamble;
701 	bool use_short_slot;
702 	bool enable_beacon;
703 	u8 dtim_period;
704 	u16 beacon_int;
705 	u16 assoc_capability;
706 	u64 sync_tsf;
707 	u32 sync_device_ts;
708 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
709 	u32 basic_rates;
710 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
711 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
712 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
713 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
714 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
715 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
716 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
717 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
718 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
719 	bool qos;
720 	bool hidden_ssid;
721 	int txpower;
722 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
723 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
724 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
725 	u16 max_idle_period;
726 	bool protected_keep_alive;
727 	bool ftm_responder;
728 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
729 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
730 	bool nontransmitted;
731 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
732 	u8 bssid_index;
733 	u8 bssid_indicator;
734 	bool ema_ap;
735 	u8 profile_periodicity;
736 	struct {
737 		u32 params;
738 		u16 nss_set;
739 	} he_oper;
740 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
741 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
742 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
743 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
744 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
745 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
746 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
747 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
748 	u8 pwr_reduction;
749 	bool eht_support;
750 	u16 eht_puncturing;
751 
752 	bool csa_active;
753 	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
754 
755 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
756 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
757 
758 	bool color_change_active;
759 	u8 color_change_color;
760 
761 	bool ht_ldpc;
762 	bool vht_ldpc;
763 	bool he_ldpc;
764 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
765 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
766 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
767 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
768 	bool he_su_beamformer;
769 	bool he_su_beamformee;
770 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
771 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
772 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
773 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
774 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
775 };
776 
777 /**
778  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
779  *
780  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
781  *
782  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
783  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
784  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
785  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
786  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
787  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
788  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
789  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
790  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
791  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
792  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
793  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
794  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
795  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
796  *	station
797  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
798  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
799  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
800  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
801  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
802  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
803  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
804  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
805  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
806  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
807  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
808  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
809  *	hardware queue.
810  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
811  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
812  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
813  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
814  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
815  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
816  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
817  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
818  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
819  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
820  *	off-channel operation.
821  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
822  *	(header conversion)
823  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
824  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
825  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
826  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
827  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
828  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
829  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
830  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
831  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
832  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
833  *	queue gets full.
834  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
835  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
836  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
837  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
838  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
839  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
840  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
841  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
842  *	status to user space)
843  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
844  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
845  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
846  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
847  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
848  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
849  *	handled properly by the device.
850  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
851  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
852  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
853  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
854  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
855  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
856  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
857  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
858  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
859  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
860  *	PS-Poll responses.
861  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
862  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
863  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
864  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
865  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
866  *	monitor injection).
867  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
868  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
869  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
870  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
871  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
872  *
873  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
874  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
875  */
876 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
877 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
878 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
879 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
880 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
881 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
884 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
885 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
886 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
887 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
888 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
889 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
890 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
891 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
892 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
893 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
894 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
895 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
896 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
897 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
898 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
899 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
900 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
901 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
902 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
903 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
904 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
905 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
906 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
907 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
908 };
909 
910 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
911 
912 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
913 
914 /**
915  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
916  *
917  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
918  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
919  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
920  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
921  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
922  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
923  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
924  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
925  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
926  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
927  *	it can be sent out.
928  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
929  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
930  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
931  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
932  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
933  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
934  *	for sequence number assignment
935  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
936  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
937  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
938  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
939  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
940  *	it's intended for an MLD.
941  *
942  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
943  */
944 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
945 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
946 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
947 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
948 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
949 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
950 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
951 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
952 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
953 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
954 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
955 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
956 };
957 
958 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
959 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
960 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
961 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
962 
963 /**
964  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
965  *
966  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
967  *
968  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
969  */
970 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
971 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
972 };
973 
974 /*
975  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
976  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
977  */
978 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
979 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
980 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
981 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
982 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
983 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
984 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
985 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
986 
987 /**
988  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
989  *	Rate Control algorithm.
990  *
991  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
992  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
993  *
994  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
995  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
996  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
997  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
998  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
999  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1000  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1001  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1002  *	Greenfield mode.
1003  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1004  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1005  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1006  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1007  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1008  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1009  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1010  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1011  */
1012 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1013 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1014 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1015 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1016 
1017 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1018 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1019 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1020 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1021 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1022 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1023 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1024 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1025 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1026 };
1027 
1028 
1029 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1030 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1031 
1032 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1033 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1034 
1035 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1036 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1037 
1038 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1039 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1040 
1041 /**
1042  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1043  *
1044  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1045  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1046  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1047  *
1048  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1049  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1050  *
1051  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1052  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1053  *
1054  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1055  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1056  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1057  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1058  * information::
1059  *
1060  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1061  *
1062  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1063  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1064  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1065  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1066  * information should then contain::
1067  *
1068  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1069  *
1070  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1071  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1072  */
1073 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1074 	s8 idx;
1075 	u16 count:5,
1076 	    flags:11;
1077 } __packed;
1078 
1079 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1080 
1081 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1082 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1083 {
1084 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1085 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1086 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1087 }
1088 
1089 static inline u8
1090 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1091 {
1092 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1093 }
1094 
1095 static inline u8
1096 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1097 {
1098 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1099 }
1100 
1101 /**
1102  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1103  *
1104  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1105  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1106  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1107  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1108  *
1109  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1110  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1111  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1112  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1113  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1114  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1115  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1116  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1117  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1118  * @control: union part for control data
1119  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1120  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1121  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1122  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1123  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1124  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1125  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1126  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1127  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1128  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1129  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1130  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1131  * @pad: padding
1132  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1133  * @status: union part for status data
1134  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1135  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1136  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1137  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1138  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1139  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1140  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1141  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1142  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1143  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1144  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1145  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1146  * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
1147  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1148  * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1149  * 	relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1150  * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1151  */
1152 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1153 	/* common information */
1154 	u32 flags;
1155 	u32 band:3,
1156 	    status_data_idr:1,
1157 	    status_data:13,
1158 	    hw_queue:4,
1159 	    tx_time_est:10;
1160 	/* 1 free bit */
1161 
1162 	union {
1163 		struct {
1164 			union {
1165 				/* rate control */
1166 				struct {
1167 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1168 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1169 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1170 					u8 use_rts:1;
1171 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1172 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1173 					u8 skip_table:1;
1174 					/* 2 bytes free */
1175 				};
1176 				/* only needed before rate control */
1177 				unsigned long jiffies;
1178 			};
1179 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1180 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1181 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1182 			u32 flags;
1183 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1184 		} control;
1185 		struct {
1186 			u64 cookie;
1187 		} ack;
1188 		struct {
1189 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1190 			s32 ack_signal;
1191 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1192 			u8 ampdu_len;
1193 			u8 antenna;
1194 			u8 pad;
1195 			u16 tx_time;
1196 			u8 flags;
1197 			u8 pad2;
1198 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1199 		} status;
1200 		struct {
1201 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1202 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1203 			u8 pad[4];
1204 
1205 			void *rate_driver_data[
1206 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1207 		};
1208 		void *driver_data[
1209 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1210 	};
1211 };
1212 
1213 static inline u16
1214 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1215 {
1216 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1217 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1218 	 */
1219 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1220 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1221 }
1222 
1223 static inline u16
1224 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1225 {
1226 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1227 }
1228 
1229 /***
1230  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1231  *
1232  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1233  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1234  *
1235  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1236  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1237  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1238  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1239  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1240  */
1241 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1242 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1243 	u8 try_count;
1244 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1245 };
1246 
1247 /**
1248  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1249  *
1250  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1251  * @info: Basic tx status information
1252  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1253  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1254  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1255  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1256  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1257  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1258  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1259  */
1260 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1261 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1262 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1263 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1264 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1265 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1266 	u8 n_rates;
1267 
1268 	struct list_head *free_list;
1269 };
1270 
1271 /**
1272  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1273  *
1274  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1275  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1276  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1277  *
1278  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1279  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1280  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1281  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1282  */
1283 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1284 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1285 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1286 	const u8 *common_ies;
1287 	size_t common_ie_len;
1288 };
1289 
1290 
1291 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1292 {
1293 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1294 }
1295 
1296 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1297 {
1298 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1299 }
1300 
1301 /**
1302  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1303  *
1304  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1305  *
1306  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1307  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1308  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1309  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1310  *
1311  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1312  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1313  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1314  */
1315 static inline void
1316 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1317 {
1318 	int i;
1319 
1320 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1321 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1322 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1323 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1324 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1325 	/* clear the rate counts */
1326 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1327 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1328 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1329 }
1330 
1331 
1332 /**
1333  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1334  *
1335  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1336  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1337  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1338  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1339  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1340  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1341  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1342  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1343  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1344  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1345  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1346  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1347  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1348  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1349  *	de-duplication by itself.
1350  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1351  *	the frame.
1352  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1353  *	the frame.
1354  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1355  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1356  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1357  *	merging.
1358  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1359  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1360  *	(including FCS) was received.
1361  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1362  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1363  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1364  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1365  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1366  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1367  *	each A-MPDU
1368  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1369  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1370  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1371  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1372  *	on this subframe
1373  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1374  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1375  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1376  *	done by the hardware
1377  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1378  *	processing it in any regular way.
1379  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1380  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1381  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1382  *	monitor interfaces.
1383  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1384  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1385  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1386  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1387  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1388  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1389  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1390  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1391  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1392  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1393  *	interleaved with other frames.
1394  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1395  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1396  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1397  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1398  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1399  *	in the skb.
1400  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1401  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1402  *	the first subframe.
1403  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1404  *	be done in the hardware.
1405  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1406  *	frame
1407  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1408  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1409  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1410  *
1411  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1412  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1413  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1414  *	 - DATA5_GI
1415  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1416  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1417  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1418  *
1419  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1420  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1421  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1422  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1423  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1424  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1425  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1426  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1427  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1428  *	hardware or driver)
1429  */
1430 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1431 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1432 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1433 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= BIT(2),
1434 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1435 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1436 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1437 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1438 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= BIT(7),
1439 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1440 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1441 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1442 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1443 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1444 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1445 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1446 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1447 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= BIT(16),
1448 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(17),
1449 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1450 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1451 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1452 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1453 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1454 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1455 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1456 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1457 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1458 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1459 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1460 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1461 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1462 };
1463 
1464 /**
1465  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1466  *
1467  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1468  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1469  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1470  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1471  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1472  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1473  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1474  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1475  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1476  */
1477 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1478 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1479 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1480 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1481 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1482 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1483 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1484 };
1485 
1486 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1487 
1488 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1489 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1490 	RX_ENC_HT,
1491 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1492 	RX_ENC_HE,
1493 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1494 };
1495 
1496 /**
1497  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1498  *
1499  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1500  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1501  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1502  *
1503  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1504  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1505  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1506  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1507  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1508  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1509  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1510  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1511  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1512  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1513  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1514  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1515  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1516  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1517  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1518  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1519  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1520  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1521  *	values were filled.
1522  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1523  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1524  * @antenna: antenna used
1525  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1526  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1527  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1528  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1529  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1530  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1531  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1532  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1533  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1534  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1535  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1536  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1537  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1538  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1539  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1540  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1541  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1542  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1543  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1544  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1545  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1546  *	@link_valid.
1547  */
1548 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1549 	u64 mactime;
1550 	union {
1551 		u64 boottime_ns;
1552 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1553 	};
1554 	u32 device_timestamp;
1555 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1556 	u32 flag;
1557 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1558 	u8 enc_flags;
1559 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1560 	union {
1561 		struct {
1562 			u8 he_ru:3;
1563 			u8 he_gi:2;
1564 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1565 		};
1566 		struct {
1567 			u8 ru:4;
1568 			u8 gi:2;
1569 		} eht;
1570 	};
1571 	u8 rate_idx;
1572 	u8 nss;
1573 	u8 rx_flags;
1574 	u8 band;
1575 	u8 antenna;
1576 	s8 signal;
1577 	u8 chains;
1578 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1579 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1580 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1581 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1582 };
1583 
1584 static inline u32
1585 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1586 {
1587 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1588 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1589 }
1590 
1591 /**
1592  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1593  *
1594  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1595  *
1596  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1597  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1598  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1599  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1600  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1601  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1602  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1603  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1604  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1605  *	for more.
1606  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1607  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1608  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1609  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1610  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1611  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1612  *	operating channel.
1613  */
1614 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1615 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1616 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1617 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1618 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1619 };
1620 
1621 
1622 /**
1623  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1624  *
1625  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1626  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1627  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1628  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1629  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1630  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1631  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1632  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1633  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1634  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1635  */
1636 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1637 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1638 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1639 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1640 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1641 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1642 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1643 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1644 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1645 };
1646 
1647 /**
1648  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1649  *
1650  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1651  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1652  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1653  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1654  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1655  */
1656 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1657 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1658 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1659 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1660 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1661 
1662 	/* keep last */
1663 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1664 };
1665 
1666 /**
1667  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1668  *
1669  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1670  *
1671  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1672  *
1673  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1674  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1675  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1676  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1677  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1678  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1679  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1680  *
1681  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1682  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1683  *
1684  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1685  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1686  *
1687  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1688  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1689  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1690  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1691  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1692  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1693  *
1694  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1695  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1696  *	configured for an HT channel.
1697  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1698  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1699  */
1700 struct ieee80211_conf {
1701 	u32 flags;
1702 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1703 
1704 	u16 listen_interval;
1705 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1706 
1707 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1708 
1709 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1710 	bool radar_enabled;
1711 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1712 };
1713 
1714 /**
1715  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1716  *
1717  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1718  * operation.
1719  *
1720  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1721  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1722  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1723  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1724  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1725  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1726  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1727  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1728  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1729  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1730  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1731   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1732   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1733  */
1734 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1735 	u64 timestamp;
1736 	u32 device_timestamp;
1737 	bool block_tx;
1738 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1739 	u8 count;
1740 	u32 delay;
1741 };
1742 
1743 /**
1744  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1745  *
1746  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1747  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1748  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1749  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1750  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1751  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1752  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1753  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1754  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1755  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1756  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1757  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1758  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1759  * @IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE: disable user configuration of
1760  *	SMPS mode via debugfs.
1761  */
1762 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1763 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1764 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1765 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1766 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1767 	IEEE80211_VIF_DISABLE_SMPS_OVERRIDE	= BIT(4),
1768 };
1769 
1770 
1771 /**
1772  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1773  *
1774  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1775  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1776  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1777  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1778  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1779  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1780  *	mac80211.
1781  */
1782 
1783 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1784 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1785 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1786 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1787 };
1788 
1789 /**
1790  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1791  * @assoc: association status
1792  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1793  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1794  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1795  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1796  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1797  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002k.
1798  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1799  *	P802.11be_D2.2 Figure 9-1002j.
1800  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1801  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1802  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1803  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1804  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1805  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1806  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1807  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1808  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1809  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1810  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1811  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1812  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1813  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1814  *	(station mode only)
1815  */
1816 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1817 	/* association related data */
1818 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1819 	bool ibss_creator;
1820 	bool ps;
1821 	u16 aid;
1822 	u16 eml_cap;
1823 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1824 
1825 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1826 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1827 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1828 	size_t ssid_len;
1829 	bool s1g;
1830 	bool idle;
1831 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1832 };
1833 
1834 /**
1835  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1836  *
1837  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1838  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1839  *
1840  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1841  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1842  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1843  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1844  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1845  *	indexed by link ID
1846  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1847  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1848  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1849  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1850  * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1851  *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1852  * @addr: address of this interface
1853  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1854  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1855  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1856  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1857  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1858  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1859  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1860  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1861  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1862  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1863  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1864  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1865  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1866  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1867  *	restrictions.
1868  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1869  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1870  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1871  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1872  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1873  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1874  *	interface.
1875  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1876  *	for this interface.
1877  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1878  *	sizeof(void \*).
1879  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1880  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1881  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1882  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1883  */
1884 struct ieee80211_vif {
1885 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1886 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1887 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1888 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1889 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links;
1890 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1891 	bool p2p;
1892 
1893 	u8 cab_queue;
1894 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1895 
1896 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1897 
1898 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1899 	u32 driver_flags;
1900 	u32 offload_flags;
1901 
1902 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1903 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1904 #endif
1905 
1906 	bool probe_req_reg;
1907 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1908 
1909 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1910 
1911 	/* must be last */
1912 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1913 };
1914 
1915 /**
1916  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1917  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1918  * Return: the usable link bitmap
1919  */
1920 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1921 {
1922 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1923 }
1924 
1925 /**
1926  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1927  * @vif: the vif
1928  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1929  */
1930 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1931 {
1932 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1933 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
1934 }
1935 
1936 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1937 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1938 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1939 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1940 		    (link = rcu_dereference((vif)->link_conf[link_id])))
1941 
1942 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1943 {
1944 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1945 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1946 #endif
1947 	return false;
1948 }
1949 
1950 /**
1951  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1952  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1953  *
1954  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1955  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1956  *
1957  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1958  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1959  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1960  */
1961 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1962 
1963 /**
1964  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1965  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1966  *
1967  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1968  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1969  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
1970  */
1971 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1972 
1973 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1974 {
1975 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
1976 }
1977 
1978 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
1979 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1980 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
1981 
1982 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
1983 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
1984 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
1985 
1986 /**
1987  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1988  *
1989  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1990  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1991  *
1992  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1993  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1994  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1995  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1996  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1997  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1998  *	generation in software.
1999  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2000  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2001  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2002  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2003  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2004  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2005  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2006  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2007  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2008  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2009  *	MIC.
2010  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2011  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2012  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2013  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2014  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2015  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2016  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2017  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2018  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2019  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2020  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2021  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2022  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2023  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2024  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2025  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2026  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2027  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2028  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2029  *	generation only
2030  */
2031 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2032 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2033 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2034 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2035 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2036 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2037 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2038 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2039 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2040 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2041 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2042 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2043 };
2044 
2045 /**
2046  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2047  *
2048  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2049  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2050  *
2051  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2052  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2053  *	encrypted in hardware.
2054  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2055  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2056  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2057  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2058  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2059  * @keylen: key material length
2060  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2061  * 	data block:
2062  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2063  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2064  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2065  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2066  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2067  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2068  */
2069 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2070 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2071 	u32 cipher;
2072 	u8 icv_len;
2073 	u8 iv_len;
2074 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2075 	s8 keyidx;
2076 	u16 flags;
2077 	s8 link_id;
2078 	u8 keylen;
2079 	u8 key[];
2080 };
2081 
2082 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2083 
2084 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2085 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2086 
2087 /**
2088  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2089  *
2090  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2091  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2092  *	reverse order than in packet)
2093  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2094  *	reverse order than in packet)
2095  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2096  *	reverse order than in packet)
2097  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2098  *	reverse order than in packet)
2099  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2100  */
2101 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2102 	union {
2103 		struct {
2104 			u32 iv32;
2105 			u16 iv16;
2106 		} tkip;
2107 		struct {
2108 			u8 pn[6];
2109 		} ccmp;
2110 		struct {
2111 			u8 pn[6];
2112 		} aes_cmac;
2113 		struct {
2114 			u8 pn[6];
2115 		} aes_gmac;
2116 		struct {
2117 			u8 pn[6];
2118 		} gcmp;
2119 		struct {
2120 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2121 			u8 seq_len;
2122 		} hw;
2123 	};
2124 };
2125 
2126 /**
2127  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2128  *
2129  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2130  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2131  *
2132  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2133  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2134  */
2135 enum set_key_cmd {
2136 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2137 };
2138 
2139 /**
2140  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2141  *
2142  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2143  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2144  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2145  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2146  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2147  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2148  */
2149 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2150 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2151 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2152 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2153 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2154 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2155 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2156 };
2157 
2158 /**
2159  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2160  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2161  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2162  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2163  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2164  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2165  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2166  *
2167  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2168  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2169  */
2170 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2171 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2172 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2173 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2174 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2175 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2176 };
2177 
2178 /**
2179  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2180  *
2181  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2182  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2183  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2184  */
2185 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2186 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2187 	struct {
2188 		s8 idx;
2189 		u8 count;
2190 		u8 count_cts;
2191 		u8 count_rts;
2192 		u16 flags;
2193 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2194 };
2195 
2196 /**
2197  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2198  *
2199  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2200  *
2201  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2202  *	to the STA.
2203  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2204  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2205  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2206  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2207  *	per peer TPC.
2208  */
2209 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2210 	s16 power;
2211 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2212 };
2213 
2214 /**
2215  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2216  *
2217  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2218  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2219  *
2220  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2221  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2222  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2223  *
2224  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2225  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2226  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2227  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2228  *
2229  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2230  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2231  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2232  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2233  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2234  */
2235 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2236 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2237 
2238 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2239 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2240 };
2241 
2242 /**
2243  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2244  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2245  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2246  *
2247  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2248  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2249  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2250  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2251  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2252  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2253  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2254  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2255  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2256  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2257  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2258  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2259  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2260  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2261  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2262  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2263  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2264  *	the station moves to associated state.
2265  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2266  *
2267  */
2268 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2269 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2270 
2271 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2272 	u8 link_id;
2273 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2274 
2275 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2276 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2277 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2278 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2279 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2280 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2281 
2282 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2283 
2284 	u8 rx_nss;
2285 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2286 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2287 };
2288 
2289 /**
2290  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2291  *
2292  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2293  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2294  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2295  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2296  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2297  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2298  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2299  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2300  *
2301  * @addr: MAC address
2302  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2303  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2304  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2305  *	Can be modified by driver.
2306  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2307  *	otherwise always false)
2308  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2309  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2310  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2311  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2312  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2313  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2314  * @rates: rate control selection table
2315  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2316  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2317  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2318  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2319  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2320  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2321  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2322  *	unlimited.
2323  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2324  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2325  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2326  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2327  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2328  *	is used for non-data frames
2329  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2330  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2331  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2332  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2333  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2334  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2335  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2336  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2337  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2338  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2339  *	by the AP.
2340  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2341  */
2342 struct ieee80211_sta {
2343 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2344 	u16 aid;
2345 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2346 	bool wme;
2347 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2348 	u8 max_sp;
2349 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2350 	bool tdls;
2351 	bool tdls_initiator;
2352 	bool mfp;
2353 	bool mlo;
2354 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2355 
2356 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2357 
2358 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2359 
2360 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2361 
2362 	u16 valid_links;
2363 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2364 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2365 
2366 	/* must be last */
2367 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2368 };
2369 
2370 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2371 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2372 #else
2373 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2374 {
2375 	return true;
2376 }
2377 #endif
2378 
2379 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2380 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2381 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2382 
2383 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2384 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2385 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2386 
2387 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2388 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2389 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2390 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2391 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)))
2392 
2393 /**
2394  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2395  *
2396  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2397  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2398  *
2399  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2400  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2401  */
2402 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2403 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2404 };
2405 
2406 /**
2407  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2408  *
2409  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2410  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2411  */
2412 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2413 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2414 };
2415 
2416 /**
2417  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2418  *
2419  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2420  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2421  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2422  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2423  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2424  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2425  *
2426  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2427  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2428  */
2429 struct ieee80211_txq {
2430 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2431 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2432 	u8 tid;
2433 	u8 ac;
2434 
2435 	/* must be last */
2436 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2437 };
2438 
2439 /**
2440  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2441  *
2442  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2443  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2444  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2445  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2446  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2447  *
2448  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2449  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2450  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2451  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2452  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2453  *	algorithm.
2454  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2455  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2456  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2457  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2458  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2459  *	CCK frames.
2460  *
2461  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2462  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2463  *	the FCS at the end.
2464  *
2465  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2466  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2467  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2468  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2469  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2470  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2471  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2472  *
2473  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2474  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2475  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2476  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2477  *
2478  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2479  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2480  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2481  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2482  *
2483  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2484  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2485  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2486  *
2487  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2488  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2489  *
2490  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2491  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2492  *
2493  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2494  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2495  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2496  *
2497  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2498  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2499  *
2500  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2501  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2502  *
2503  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2504  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2505  *	the stack.
2506  *
2507  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2508  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2509  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2510  *
2511  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2512  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2513  *	dtim_period).
2514  *
2515  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2516  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2517  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2518  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2519  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2520  *	only in that case.
2521  *
2522  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2523  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2524  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2525  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2526  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2527  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2528  *
2529  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2530  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2531  *	software.
2532  *
2533  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2534  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2535  *	active interfaces.
2536  *
2537  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2538  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2539  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2540  *
2541  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2542  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2543  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2544  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2545  *	supported cipher suites.
2546  *
2547  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2548  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2549  *	for frames.
2550  *
2551  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2552  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2553  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2554  *	control for more details.
2555  *
2556  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2557  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2558  *
2559  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2560  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2561  *	is supported.
2562  *
2563  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2564  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2565  *
2566  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2567  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2568  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2569  *
2570  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2571  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2572  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2573  *	CSA frame.
2574  *
2575  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2576  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2577  *
2578  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2579  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2580  *
2581  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2582  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2583  *
2584  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2585  *	within A-MPDU.
2586  *
2587  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2588  *	for sent beacons.
2589  *
2590  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2591  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2592  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2593  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2594  *
2595  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2596  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2597  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2598  *	timeout.
2599  *
2600  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2601  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2602  *
2603  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2604  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2605  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2606  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2607  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2608  *
2609  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2610  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2611  *
2612  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2613  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2614  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2615  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2616  *
2617  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2618  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2619  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2620  *
2621  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2622  *	TDLS links.
2623  *
2624  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2625  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2626  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2627  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2628  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2629  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2630  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2631  *
2632  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2633  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2634  *
2635  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2636  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2637  *
2638  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2639  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2640  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2641  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2642  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2643  *
2644  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2645  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2646  *	TXQs to start with.
2647  *
2648  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2649  *	length in tx status information
2650  *
2651  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2652  *
2653  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2654  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2655  *
2656  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2657  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2658  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2659  *
2660  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2661  *	offload
2662  *
2663  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2664  *	offload
2665  *
2666  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2667  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2668  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2669  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2670  *	the stack.
2671  *
2672  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2673  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2674  *
2675  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2676  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2677  *
2678  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2679  */
2680 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2681 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2682 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2683 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2684 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2685 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2686 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2687 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2688 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2689 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2690 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2691 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2692 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2693 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2694 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2695 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2696 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2697 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2698 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2699 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2700 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2701 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2702 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2703 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2704 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2705 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2706 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2707 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2708 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2709 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2710 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2711 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2712 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2713 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2714 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2715 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2716 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2717 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2718 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2719 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2720 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2721 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2722 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2723 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2724 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2725 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2726 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2727 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2728 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2729 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2730 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2731 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2732 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2733 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2734 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2735 
2736 	/* keep last, obviously */
2737 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2738 };
2739 
2740 /**
2741  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2742  *
2743  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2744  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2745  *
2746  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2747  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2748  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2749  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2750  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2751  *
2752  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2753  *
2754  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2755  *	along with this structure.
2756  *
2757  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2758  *
2759  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2760  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2761  *
2762  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2763  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2764  *
2765  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2766  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2767  *
2768  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2769  *	that HW supports
2770  *
2771  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2772  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2773  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2774  *
2775  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2776  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2777  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2778  *
2779  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2780  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2781  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2782  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2783  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2784  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2785  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2786  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2787  *
2788  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2789  *	can handle.
2790  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2791  *	the hw can report back.
2792  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2793  *
2794  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2795  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2796  *	aggregation.
2797  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2798  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2799  *	it shouldn't be set.
2800  *
2801  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2802  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2803  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2804  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2805  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2806  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2807  *
2808  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2809  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2810  *
2811  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2812  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2813  *
2814  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2815  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2816  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2817  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2818  *
2819  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2820  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2821  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2822  *
2823  * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2824  *
2825  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2826  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2827  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2828  *	device_timestamp.
2829  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2830  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2831  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2832  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2833  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2834  *
2835  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2836  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2837  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2838  *
2839  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2840  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2841  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2842  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2843  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2844  *	neither enabled.
2845  *
2846  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2847  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2848  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2849  *
2850  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2851  *	device.
2852  *
2853  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2854  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2855  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2856  *
2857  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2858  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2859  *
2860  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2861  *
2862  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2863  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2864  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2865  *
2866  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2867  */
2868 struct ieee80211_hw {
2869 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2870 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2871 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2872 	void *priv;
2873 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2874 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2875 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2876 	int vif_data_size;
2877 	int sta_data_size;
2878 	int chanctx_data_size;
2879 	int txq_data_size;
2880 	u16 queues;
2881 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2882 	s8 max_signal;
2883 	u8 max_rates;
2884 	u8 max_report_rates;
2885 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2886 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2887 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2888 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2889 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2890 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2891 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2892 	struct {
2893 		int units_pos;
2894 		s16 accuracy;
2895 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2896 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2897 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2898 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2899 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2900 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2901 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2902 	u32 max_mtu;
2903 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2904 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2905 };
2906 
2907 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2908 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2909 {
2910 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2911 }
2912 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2913 
2914 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2915 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2916 {
2917 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2918 }
2919 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2920 
2921 /**
2922  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2923  *
2924  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2925  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2926  */
2927 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2928 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2929 
2930 	/* Keep last */
2931 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2932 };
2933 
2934 /**
2935  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2936  *
2937  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2938  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2939  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2940  * @status: channel-switch response status
2941  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2942  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2943  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2944  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2945  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2946  */
2947 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2948 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2949 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2950 	u8 action_code;
2951 	u32 status;
2952 	u32 timestamp;
2953 	u16 switch_time;
2954 	u16 switch_timeout;
2955 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2956 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2957 };
2958 
2959 /**
2960  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2961  *
2962  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2963  *
2964  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2965  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2966  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2967  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2968  * is already used internally by mac80211.
2969  *
2970  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2971  */
2972 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2973 
2974 /**
2975  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2976  *
2977  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2978  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2979  */
2980 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2981 {
2982 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2983 }
2984 
2985 /**
2986  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2987  *
2988  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2989  * @addr: the address to set
2990  */
2991 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2992 {
2993 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2994 }
2995 
2996 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
2997 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2998 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2999 {
3000 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3001 		return NULL;
3002 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3003 }
3004 
3005 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3006 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3007 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3008 {
3009 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3010 		return NULL;
3011 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3012 }
3013 
3014 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3015 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3016 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3017 {
3018 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3019 		return NULL;
3020 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3021 }
3022 
3023 /**
3024  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3025  * @hw: the hardware
3026  * @skb: the skb
3027  *
3028  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3029  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3030  */
3031 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3032 
3033 /**
3034  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3035  *
3036  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3037  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3038  *
3039  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3040  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3041  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3042  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3043  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3044  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3045  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3046  *
3047  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3048  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3049  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3050  *
3051  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3052  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3053  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3054  * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
3055  *
3056  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3057  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3058  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3059  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3060  *
3061  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3062  *
3063  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3064  * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
3065  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3066  * based on the receive flags.
3067  *
3068  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3069  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3070  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3071  * keys.
3072  *
3073  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3074  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3075  * handler.
3076  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3077  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3078  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3079  * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3080  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3081  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3082  *
3083  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3084  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3085  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3086  *
3087  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3088  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3089  * requirements:
3090  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3091       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3092    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3093       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3094    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3095       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3096       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3097    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3098    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3099  */
3100 
3101 /**
3102  * DOC: Powersave support
3103  *
3104  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3105  *
3106  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
3107  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3108  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3109  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3110  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3111  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3112  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3113  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3114  *
3115  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3116  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3117  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3118  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3119  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3120  *
3121  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3122  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3123  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3124  *
3125  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3126  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3127  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3128  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3129  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3130  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3131  * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3132  *
3133  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3134  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3135  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3136  * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
3137  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3138  * periods.
3139  *
3140  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3141  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3142  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3143  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3144  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3145  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3146  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3147  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3148  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3149  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3150  *
3151  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3152  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3153  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3154  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3155  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3156  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3157  *
3158  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3159  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3160  */
3161 
3162 /**
3163  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3164  *
3165  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3166  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3167  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3168  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3169  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3170  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3171  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3172  *
3173  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3174  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3175  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3176  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3177  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3178  *
3179  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3180  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3181  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3182  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3183  *
3184  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3185  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3186  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3187  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3188  *
3189  *  - a list of information element IDs
3190  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3191  *
3192  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3193  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3194  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3195  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3196  * vendor information elements.
3197  *
3198  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3199  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3200  *
3201  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
3202  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3203  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3204  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3205  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3206  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3207  *
3208  *
3209  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3210  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3211  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3212  * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
3213  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3214  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3215  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3216  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3217  *
3218  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3219  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3220  * signal strength threshold checking.
3221  */
3222 
3223 /**
3224  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3225  *
3226  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3227  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3228  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3229  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3230  *
3231  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3232  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3233  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3234  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3235  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3236  * hardware flags.
3237  *
3238  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3239  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3240  * turned off otherwise.
3241  *
3242  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3243  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3244  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3245  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3246  */
3247 
3248 /**
3249  * DOC: Frame filtering
3250  *
3251  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3252  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3253  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3254  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3255  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3256  *
3257  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3258  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3259  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3260  *
3261  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3262  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3263  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3264  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3265  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3266  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3267  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3268  *
3269  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3270  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3271  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3272  * or dropped.
3273  *
3274  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3275  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3276  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3277  * the flag, but not clear it.
3278  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3279  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3280  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3281  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3282  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3283  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3284  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3285  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3286  */
3287 
3288 /**
3289  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3290  *
3291  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3292  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3293  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3294  *
3295  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3296  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3297  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3298  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3299  * the driver code.
3300  *
3301  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3302  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3303  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3304  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3305  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3306  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3307  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3308  *
3309  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3310  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3311  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3312  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3313  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3314  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3315  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3316  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3317  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3318  * @sta_notify callback.
3319  *
3320  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3321  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3322  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3323  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3324  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3325  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3326  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3327  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3328  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3329  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3330  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3331  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3332  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3333  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3334  *
3335  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3336  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3337  *
3338  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3339  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3340  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3341  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3342  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3343  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3344  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3345  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3346  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3347  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3348  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3349  *
3350  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3351  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3352  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3353  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3354  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3355  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3356  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3357  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3358  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3359  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
3360  * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3361  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3362  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3363  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3364  *
3365  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3366  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3367  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3368  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3369  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3370  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3371  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3372  *
3373  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3374  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3375  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3376  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3377  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3378  *
3379  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3380  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3381  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3382  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3383  */
3384 
3385 /**
3386  * DOC: HW queue control
3387  *
3388  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3389  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3390  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3391  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3392  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3393  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3394  *
3395  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3396  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3397  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3398  *
3399  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3400  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3401  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3402  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3403  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3404  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3405  * the hardware queue.
3406  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3407  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3408  *
3409  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3410  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3411  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3412  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3413  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3414  *
3415  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3416  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3417  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3418  * off-channel queue:         9
3419  *
3420  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3421  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3422  *
3423  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3424  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3425  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3426  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3427  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3428  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3429  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3430  *
3431  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3432  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3433  *
3434  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3435  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3436  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3437  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3438  */
3439 
3440 /**
3441  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3442  *
3443  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3444  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3445  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3446  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3447  *
3448  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3449  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3450  *	multicast address.
3451  *
3452  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3453  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3454  *
3455  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3456  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3457  *
3458  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3459  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3460  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3461  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3462  *	honour this flag if possible.
3463  *
3464  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3465  *	station
3466  *
3467  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3468  *
3469  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3470  *
3471  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3472  *
3473  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3474  */
3475 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3476 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3477 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3478 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3479 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3480 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3481 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3482 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3483 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3484 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3485 };
3486 
3487 /**
3488  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3489  *
3490  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3491  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3492  *
3493  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3494  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3495  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3496  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3497  *
3498  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3499  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3500  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3501  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3502  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3503  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3504  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3505  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3506  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3507  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3508  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3509  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3510  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3511  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3512  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3513  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3514  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3515  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3516  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3517  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3518  */
3519 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3520 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3521 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3522 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3523 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3524 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3525 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3526 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3527 };
3528 
3529 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3530 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3531 
3532 /**
3533  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3534  *
3535  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3536  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3537  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3538  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3539  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3540  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3541  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3542  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3543  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3544  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3545  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3546  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3547  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3548  */
3549 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3550 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3551 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3552 	u16 tid;
3553 	u16 ssn;
3554 	u16 buf_size;
3555 	bool amsdu;
3556 	u16 timeout;
3557 };
3558 
3559 /**
3560  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3561  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3562  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3563  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3564  */
3565 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3566 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3567 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3568 };
3569 
3570 /**
3571  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3572  *
3573  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3574  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3575  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3576  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3577  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3578  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3579  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3580  *	the peer.
3581  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3582  *	by the peer
3583  */
3584 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3585 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3586 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3587 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3588 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3589 };
3590 
3591 /**
3592  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3593  *
3594  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3595  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3596  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3597  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3598  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3599  *
3600  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3601  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3602  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3603  */
3604 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3605 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3606 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3607 };
3608 
3609 /**
3610  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3611  *
3612  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3613  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3614  *
3615  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3616  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3617  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3618  *	of wowlan configuration)
3619  */
3620 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3621 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3622 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3623 };
3624 
3625 /**
3626  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3627  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3628  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3629  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3630  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3631  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3632  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3633  */
3634 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3635 	u16 duration;
3636 	u16 subtype;
3637 	u8 success:1;
3638 };
3639 
3640 /**
3641  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3642  *
3643  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3644  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3645  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3646  *
3647  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3648  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3649  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3650  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3651  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3652  *	Must be atomic.
3653  *
3654  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3655  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3656  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3657  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3658  *	or zero.
3659  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3660  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3661  *	is added.
3662  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3663  *
3664  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3665  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3666  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3667  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3668  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3669  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3670  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3671  *
3672  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3673  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3674  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3675  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3676  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3677  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3678  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3679  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3680  *	must return 1 from this function.
3681  *
3682  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3683  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3684  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3685  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3686  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3687  *
3688  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3689  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3690  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3691  *	in suspend().
3692  *
3693  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3694  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3695  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3696  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3697  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3698  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3699  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3700  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3701  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3702  *
3703  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3704  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3705  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3706  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3707  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3708  *
3709  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3710  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3711  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3712  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3713  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3714  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3715  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3716  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3717  *
3718  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3719  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3720  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3721  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3722  *
3723  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3724  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3725  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3726  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3727  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3728  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3729  *	can sleep.
3730  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3731  *	are not implemented.
3732  *
3733  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3734  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3735  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3736  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3737  *	The callback can sleep.
3738  *
3739  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3740  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3741  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3742  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3743  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3744  *	non-MLO connections.
3745  *	The callback can sleep.
3746  *
3747  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3748  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3749  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3750  *
3751  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3752  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3753  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3754  *
3755  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3756  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3757  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3758  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3759  *	which flags are changed.
3760  *	This callback can sleep.
3761  *
3762  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3763  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3764  *
3765  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3766  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3767  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3768  *	is enabled.
3769  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3770  *	The callback can sleep.
3771  *
3772  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3773  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3774  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3775  *	The callback must be atomic.
3776  *
3777  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3778  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3779  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3780  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3781  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3782  *
3783  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3784  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3785  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3786  *
3787  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3788  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3789  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3790  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3791  *	that power save is disabled.
3792  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3793  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3794  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3795  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3796  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3797  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3798  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3799  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3800  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3801  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3802  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3803  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3804  *	The callback can sleep.
3805  *
3806  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3807  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3808  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3809  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3810  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3811  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3812  *	The callback can sleep.
3813  *
3814  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3815  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3816  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3817  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3818  *
3819  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3820  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3821  *
3822  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3823  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3824  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3825  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3826  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3827  *
3828  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3829  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3830  *	this notification.
3831  *	The callback can sleep.
3832  *
3833  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3834  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3835  *	The callback can sleep.
3836  *
3837  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3838  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3839  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3840  *	The callback must be atomic.
3841  *
3842  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3843  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3844  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3845  *	should be set as well.
3846  *	The callback can sleep.
3847  *
3848  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3849  *	The callback can sleep.
3850  *
3851  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3852  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3853  *
3854  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3855  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3856  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3857  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3858  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3859  *	This callback can sleep.
3860  *
3861  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3862  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3863  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3864  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3865  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3866  *
3867  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3868  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3869  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3870  *	callback can sleep.
3871  *
3872  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3873  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3874  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3875  *	callback can sleep.
3876  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3877  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3878  *
3879  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3880  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3881  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3882  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3883  *
3884  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3885  *	power for the station.
3886  *	This callback can sleep.
3887  *
3888  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3889  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3890  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3891  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3892  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3893  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3894  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3895  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3896  *	The callback can sleep.
3897  *
3898  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3899  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3900  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3901  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3902  *	in @sta_state.
3903  *	The callback can sleep.
3904  *
3905  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3906  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3907  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3908  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3909  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3910  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3911  *	Must be atomic.
3912  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3913  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3914  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3915  *
3916  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3917  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3918  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3919  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3920  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3921  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3922  *	The callback can sleep.
3923  *
3924  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3925  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3926  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3927  *	The callback can sleep.
3928  *
3929  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3930  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3931  *	required function.
3932  *	The callback can sleep.
3933  *
3934  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3935  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3936  *	required function.
3937  *	The callback can sleep.
3938  *
3939  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3940  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3941  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3942  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3943  *	The callback can sleep.
3944  *
3945  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3946  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3947  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3948  *	TSF synchronization.
3949  *	The callback can sleep.
3950  *
3951  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3952  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3953  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3954  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3955  *	The callback can sleep.
3956  *
3957  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3958  *
3959  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3960  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3961  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3962  *	The callback can sleep.
3963  *
3964  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3965  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3966  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3967  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3968  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3969  *
3970  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3971  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3972  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3973  *
3974  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3975  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3976  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3977  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3978  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3979  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
3980  *	The callback can sleep.
3981  *
3982  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
3983  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
3984  *	The callback can sleep.
3985  *
3986  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3987  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3988  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3989  *	completion of the channel switch.
3990  *
3991  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3992  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3993  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3994  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3995  *
3996  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3997  *
3998  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3999  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4000  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4001  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4002  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4003  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4004  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4005  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4006  *	must be accepted in this case.
4007  *	This callback may sleep.
4008  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4009  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4010  *
4011  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4012  *
4013  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4014  *
4015  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4016  *	queues before entering power save.
4017  *
4018  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4019  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4020  *	The callback can sleep.
4021  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4022  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4023  *	The callback must be atomic.
4024  *
4025  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4026  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4027  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4028  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4029  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4030  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4031  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4032  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4033  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4034  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4035  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4036  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4037  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4038  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4039  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4040  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4041  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4042  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4043  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4044  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4045  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4046  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4047  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4048  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4049  *	This callback must be atomic.
4050  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4051  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4052  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4053  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4054  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4055  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4056  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4057  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4058  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4059  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4060  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4061  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4062  *	This callback must be atomic.
4063  *
4064  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4065  *
4066  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4067  *
4068  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4069  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4070  *
4071  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4072  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4073  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4074  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4075  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4076  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4077  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4078  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4079  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4080  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4081  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4082  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4083  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4084  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4085  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4086  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4087  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4088  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4089  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4090  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4091  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4092  *
4093  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4094  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4095  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4096  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4097  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4098  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4099  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4100  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4101  *
4102  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4103  *	This callback may sleep.
4104  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4105  *	This callback may sleep.
4106  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4107  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4108  *	channel context with different settings
4109  *	This callback may sleep.
4110  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4111  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4112  *	This callback may sleep.
4113  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4114  *	unbound from vif.
4115  *	This callback may sleep.
4116  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4117  *	another, as specified in the list of
4118  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4119  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4120  *	This callback may sleep.
4121  *
4122  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4123  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4124  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4125  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4126  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4127  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4128  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4129  *
4130  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4131  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4132  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4133  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4134  *	This callback may sleep.
4135  *
4136  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4137  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4138  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4139  *
4140  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4141  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4142  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4143  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4144  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4145  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4146  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4147  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4148  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4149  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4150  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4151  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4152  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4153  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4154  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4155  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4156  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4157  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4158  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4159  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4160  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4161  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4162  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4163  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4164  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4165  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4166  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4167  *
4168  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4169  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4170  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4171  *
4172  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4173  *	and hardware limits.
4174  *
4175  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4176  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4177  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4178  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4179  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4180  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4181  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4182  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4183  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4184  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4185  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4186  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4187  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4188  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4189  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4190  *	the function call.
4191  *
4192  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4193  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4194  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4195  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4196  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4197  *
4198  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4199  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4200  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4201  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4202  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4203  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4204  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4205  *	changed parameters.
4206  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4207  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4208  *	this call.
4209  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4210  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4211  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4212  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4213  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4214  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4215  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4216  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4217  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4218  *
4219  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4220  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4221  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4222  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4223  *	This callback may sleep.
4224  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4225  *	This callback may sleep.
4226  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4227  *	4-address mode
4228  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4229  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4230  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4231  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4232  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4233  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4234  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4235  *	twt structure.
4236  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4237  *	from the peer.
4238  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4239  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4240  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4241  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4242  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4243  *	radar channel.
4244  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4245  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4246  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4247  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4248  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4249  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4250  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4251  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4252  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4253  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4254  *	This callback can sleep.
4255  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4256  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4257  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4258  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4259  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4260  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4261  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4262  *	that.
4263  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4264  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4265  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4266  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4267  */
4268 struct ieee80211_ops {
4269 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4270 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4271 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4272 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4273 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4274 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4275 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4276 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4277 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4278 #endif
4279 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4280 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4281 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4282 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4283 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4284 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4285 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4286 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4287 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4288 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4289 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4290 				 u64 changed);
4291 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4292 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4293 				u64 changed);
4294 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4295 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4296 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4297 				  u64 changed);
4298 
4299 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4300 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4301 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4302 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4303 
4304 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4305 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4306 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4307 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4308 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4309 				 u64 multicast);
4310 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4311 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4312 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4313 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4314 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4315 		       bool set);
4316 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4317 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4318 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4319 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4320 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4321 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4322 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4323 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4324 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4325 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4326 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4327 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4328 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4329 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4330 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4331 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4332 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4333 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4334 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4335 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4336 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4337 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4338 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4339 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4340 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4341 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4342 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4343 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4344 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4345 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4346 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4347 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4348 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4349 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4350 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4351 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4352 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4353 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4354 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4355 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4356 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4357 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4358 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4359 				 struct dentry *dir);
4360 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4361 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4362 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4363 				struct dentry *dir);
4364 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4365 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4366 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4367 				     struct dentry *dir);
4368 #endif
4369 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4370 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4371 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4372 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4373 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4374 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4375 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4376 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4377 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4378 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4379 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4380 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4381 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4382 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4383 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4384 			      u32 changed);
4385 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4386 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4387 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4388 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4389 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4390 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4391 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4392 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4393 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4394 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4395 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4396 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4397 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4398 			u64 tsf);
4399 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4400 			   s64 offset);
4401 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4402 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4403 
4404 	/**
4405 	 * @ampdu_action:
4406 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4407 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4408 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4409 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4410 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4411 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4412 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4413 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4414 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4415 	 *
4416 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4417 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4418 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4419 	 *
4420 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4421 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4422 	 *
4423 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4424 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4425 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4426 	 *
4427 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4428 	 *
4429 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4430 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4431 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4432 	 *
4433 	 * The callback can sleep.
4434 	 */
4435 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4436 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4437 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4438 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4439 		struct survey_info *survey);
4440 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4441 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4442 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4443 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4444 			    void *data, int len);
4445 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4446 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4447 			     void *data, int len);
4448 #endif
4449 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4450 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4451 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4452 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4453 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4454 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4455 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4456 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4457 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4458 
4459 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4460 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4461 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4462 				 int duration,
4463 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4464 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4465 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4466 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4467 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4468 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4469 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4470 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4471 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4472 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4474 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4475 
4476 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4477 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4478 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4479 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4480 				      bool more_data);
4481 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4482 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4483 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4484 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4485 					bool more_data);
4486 
4487 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4488 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4489 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4490 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4491 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4492 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4493 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4494 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4495 
4496 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4497 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4498 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4499 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4500 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4501 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4502 
4503 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4504 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4505 
4506 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4507 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4508 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4509 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4510 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4511 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4512 			       u32 changed);
4513 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4514 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4515 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4516 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4517 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4518 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4519 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4520 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4521 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4522 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4523 				  int n_vifs,
4524 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4525 
4526 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4527 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4528 
4529 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4530 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4531 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4532 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4533 #endif
4534 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4535 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4536 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4537 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4538 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4539 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4540 
4541 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4542 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4543 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4544 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4545 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4546 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4547 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4548 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4549 
4550 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4551 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4552 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4553 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4554 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4555 			   int *dbm);
4556 
4557 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4558 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4559 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4560 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4561 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4562 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4563 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4564 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4565 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4566 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4567 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4568 
4569 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4571 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4572 
4573 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4574 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4575 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4576 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4578 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4579 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4580 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4581 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4582 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4583 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4584 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4585 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4586 			    u8 instance_id);
4587 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4588 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4589 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4590 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4591 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4592 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4593 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4594 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4595 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4597 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4598 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4599 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4600 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4601 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4602 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4603 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4604 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4605 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4606 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4607 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4608 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4609 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4610 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4611 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4612 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4613 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4614 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4615 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4616 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4617 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4618 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4619 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4620 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4621 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4622 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4623 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4624 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4625 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4626 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4627 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4628 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4629 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4630 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4631 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4632 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4633 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4635 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4636 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4637 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4638 			    struct net_device *dev,
4639 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4640 			    void *type_data);
4641 };
4642 
4643 /**
4644  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4645  *
4646  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4647  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4648  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4649  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4650  * @priv_data_len.
4651  *
4652  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4653  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4654  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4655  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4656  *
4657  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4658  */
4659 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4660 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4661 					   const char *requested_name);
4662 
4663 /**
4664  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4665  *
4666  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4667  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4668  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4669  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4670  * @priv_data_len.
4671  *
4672  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4673  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4674  *
4675  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4676  */
4677 static inline
4678 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4679 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4680 {
4681 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4682 }
4683 
4684 /**
4685  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4686  *
4687  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4688  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4689  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4690  *
4691  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4692  *
4693  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4694  */
4695 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4696 
4697 /**
4698  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4699  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4700  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4701  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4702  */
4703 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4704 	int throughput;
4705 	int blink_time;
4706 };
4707 
4708 /**
4709  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4710  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4711  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4712  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4713  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4714  */
4715 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4716 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4717 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4718 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4719 };
4720 
4721 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4722 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4723 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4724 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4725 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4726 const char *
4727 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4728 				   unsigned int flags,
4729 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4730 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4731 #endif
4732 /**
4733  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4734  *
4735  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4736  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4737  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4738  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4739  *
4740  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4741  *
4742  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4743  */
4744 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4745 {
4746 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4747 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4748 #else
4749 	return NULL;
4750 #endif
4751 }
4752 
4753 /**
4754  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4755  *
4756  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4757  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4758  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4759  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4760  *
4761  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4762  *
4763  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4764  */
4765 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4766 {
4767 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4768 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4769 #else
4770 	return NULL;
4771 #endif
4772 }
4773 
4774 /**
4775  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4776  *
4777  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4778  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4779  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4780  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4781  *
4782  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4783  *
4784  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4785  */
4786 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4787 {
4788 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4789 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4790 #else
4791 	return NULL;
4792 #endif
4793 }
4794 
4795 /**
4796  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4797  *
4798  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4799  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4800  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4801  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4802  *
4803  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4804  *
4805  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4806  */
4807 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4808 {
4809 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4810 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4811 #else
4812 	return NULL;
4813 #endif
4814 }
4815 
4816 /**
4817  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4818  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4819  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4820  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4821  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4822  *
4823  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4824  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4825  *
4826  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4827  */
4828 static inline const char *
4829 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4830 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4831 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4832 {
4833 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4834 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4835 						  blink_table_len);
4836 #else
4837 	return NULL;
4838 #endif
4839 }
4840 
4841 /**
4842  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4843  *
4844  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4845  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4846  *
4847  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4848  */
4849 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4850 
4851 /**
4852  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4853  *
4854  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4855  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4856  * before calling this function.
4857  *
4858  * @hw: the hardware to free
4859  */
4860 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4861 
4862 /**
4863  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4864  *
4865  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4866  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4867  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4868  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4869  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4870  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4871  *
4872  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4873  */
4874 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4875 
4876 /**
4877  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4878  *
4879  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4880  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4881  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4882  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4883  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4884  *
4885  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4886  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4887  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4888  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4889  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4890  *
4891  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4892  *
4893  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4894  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4895  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4896  * @list: the destination list
4897  */
4898 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4899 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4900 
4901 /**
4902  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4903  *
4904  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4905  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4906  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4907  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4908  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4909  *
4910  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4911  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4912  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4913  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4914  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4915  *
4916  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4917  *
4918  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4919  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4920  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4921  * @napi: the NAPI context
4922  */
4923 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4924 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4925 
4926 /**
4927  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4928  *
4929  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4930  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4931  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4932  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4933  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4934  *
4935  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4936  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4937  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4938  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4939  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4940  *
4941  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4942  *
4943  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4944  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4945  */
4946 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4947 {
4948 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4949 }
4950 
4951 /**
4952  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4953  *
4954  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4955  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4956  *
4957  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4958  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4959  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4960  *
4961  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4962  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4963  */
4964 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4965 
4966 /**
4967  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4968  *
4969  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4970  * (internally disables bottom halves).
4971  *
4972  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4973  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4974  * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4975  *
4976  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4977  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4978  */
4979 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4980 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
4981 {
4982 	local_bh_disable();
4983 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4984 	local_bh_enable();
4985 }
4986 
4987 /**
4988  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4989  *
4990  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4991  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4992  * entering/leaving PS mode.
4993  *
4994  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4995  *
4996  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4997  * each other.
4998  *
4999  * @sta: currently connected sta
5000  * @start: start or stop PS
5001  *
5002  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5003  */
5004 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5005 
5006 /**
5007  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5008  *                                  (in process context)
5009  *
5010  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5011  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5012  * applies.
5013  *
5014  * @sta: currently connected sta
5015  * @start: start or stop PS
5016  *
5017  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5018  */
5019 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5020 						  bool start)
5021 {
5022 	int ret;
5023 
5024 	local_bh_disable();
5025 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5026 	local_bh_enable();
5027 
5028 	return ret;
5029 }
5030 
5031 /**
5032  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5033  * @sta: currently connected station
5034  *
5035  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5036  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5037  * connected station was received.
5038  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5039  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5040  * be serialized.
5041  */
5042 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5043 
5044 /**
5045  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5046  * @sta: currently connected station
5047  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5048  *
5049  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5050  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5051  * from a connected station was received.
5052  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5053  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5054  * serialized.
5055  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5056  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5057  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5058  * checks.
5059  */
5060 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5061 
5062 /*
5063  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5064  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5065  */
5066 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5067 
5068 /**
5069  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5070  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5071  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5072  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5073  *
5074  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5075  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5076  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5077  *
5078  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5079  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5080  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5081  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5082  *
5083  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5084  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5085  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5086  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5087  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5088  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5089  *
5090  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5091  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5092  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5093  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5094  * use this API.
5095  */
5096 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5097 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5098 
5099 /**
5100  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5101  *
5102  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5103  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5104  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5105  *
5106  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5107  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5108  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5109  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5110  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5111  */
5112 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5113 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5114 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5115 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5116 			    int max_rates);
5117 
5118 /**
5119  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5120  *
5121  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5122  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5123  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5124  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5125  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5126  * slow stations to starve).
5127  *
5128  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5129  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5130  */
5131 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5132 					   u32 thr);
5133 
5134 /**
5135  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5136  *
5137  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5138  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5139  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5140  *
5141  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5142  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5143  * @info: tx status information
5144  */
5145 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5146 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5147 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5148 
5149 /**
5150  * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
5151  *
5152  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5153  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5154  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5155  *
5156  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5157  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5158  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5159  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5160  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5161  *
5162  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5163  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5164  */
5165 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5166 			 struct sk_buff *skb);
5167 
5168 /**
5169  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5170  *
5171  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5172  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5173  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5174  *
5175  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5176  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5177  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5178  *
5179  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5180  * @status: tx status information
5181  */
5182 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5183 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5184 
5185 /**
5186  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5187  *
5188  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
5189  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5190  * specific skbs.
5191  *
5192  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5193  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5194  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5195  *
5196  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5197  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5198  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5199  * @info: tx status information
5200  */
5201 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5202 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5203 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5204 {
5205 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5206 		.sta = sta,
5207 		.info = info,
5208 	};
5209 
5210 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5211 }
5212 
5213 /**
5214  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5215  *
5216  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
5217  *
5218  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5219  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5220  * for a single hardware.
5221  *
5222  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5223  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5224  */
5225 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5226 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5227 {
5228 	local_bh_disable();
5229 	ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
5230 	local_bh_enable();
5231 }
5232 
5233 /**
5234  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5235  *
5236  * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
5237  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5238  *
5239  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
5240  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5241  *
5242  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5243  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5244  */
5245 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5246 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5247 
5248 /**
5249  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5250  *
5251  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5252  * connected STA.
5253  *
5254  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5255  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5256  */
5257 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5258 
5259 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5260 
5261 /**
5262  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5263  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5264  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5265  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5266  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5267  *	should be ignored.
5268  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5269  */
5270 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5271 	u16 tim_offset;
5272 	u16 tim_length;
5273 
5274 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5275 	u16 mbssid_off;
5276 };
5277 
5278 /**
5279  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5280  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5281  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5282  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5283  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5284  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5285  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5286  *
5287  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5288  * obtain the beacon template.
5289  *
5290  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5291  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5292  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5293  * applicable, the CSA count.
5294  *
5295  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5296  *
5297  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5298  */
5299 struct sk_buff *
5300 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5301 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5302 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5303 			      unsigned int link_id);
5304 
5305 /**
5306  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5307  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5308  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5309  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5310  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5311  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5312  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5313  *
5314  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5315  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5316  * requested index.
5317  *
5318  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5319  */
5320 struct sk_buff *
5321 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5322 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5323 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5324 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5325 
5326 /**
5327  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5328  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5329  *
5330  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5331  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5332  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5333  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5334  */
5335 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5336 	u8 cnt;
5337 	struct {
5338 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5339 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5340 	} bcn[];
5341 };
5342 
5343 /**
5344  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5345  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5346  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5347  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5348  *
5349  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5350  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5351  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5352  * one multiple BSSID element.
5353  *
5354  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5355  *
5356  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5357  *	%NULL on error.
5358  */
5359 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5360 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5361 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5362 				       unsigned int link_id);
5363 
5364 /**
5365  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5366  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5367  *
5368  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5369  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5370  */
5371 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5372 
5373 /**
5374  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5375  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5376  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5377  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5378  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5379  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5380  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5381  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5382  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5383  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5384  *
5385  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5386  * obtain the beacon frame.
5387  *
5388  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5389  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5390  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5391  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5392  *
5393  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5394  *
5395  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5396  */
5397 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5398 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5399 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5400 					 unsigned int link_id);
5401 
5402 /**
5403  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5404  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5405  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5406  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5407  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5408  *
5409  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5410  *
5411  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5412  */
5413 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5414 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5415 						   unsigned int link_id)
5416 {
5417 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5418 }
5419 
5420 /**
5421  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5422  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5423  *
5424  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5425  * This function is called implicitly when
5426  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5427  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5428  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5429  *
5430  * Return: new countdown value
5431  */
5432 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5433 
5434 /**
5435  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5436  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5437  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5438  *
5439  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5440  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5441  *
5442  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5443  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5444  */
5445 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5446 
5447 /**
5448  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5449  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5450  *
5451  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5452  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5453  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5454  */
5455 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5456 
5457 /**
5458  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5459  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5460  *
5461  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5462  */
5463 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5464 
5465 /**
5466  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5467  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5468  *
5469  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5470  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5471  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5472  */
5473 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5474 
5475 /**
5476  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5477  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5478  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5479  *
5480  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5481  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5482  *
5483  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5484  *
5485  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5486  */
5487 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5488 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5489 
5490 /**
5491  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5492  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5493  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5494  *
5495  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5496  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5497  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5498  *
5499  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5500  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5501  *
5502  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5503  */
5504 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5505 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5506 
5507 /**
5508  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5509  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5510  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5511  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5512  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5513  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5514  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5515  *	if at all possible
5516  *
5517  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5518  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5519  * BSSID and address is used.
5520  *
5521  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5522  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5523  *
5524  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5525  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5526  *
5527  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5528  */
5529 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5530 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5531 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5532 
5533 /**
5534  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5535  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5536  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5537  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5538  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5539  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5540  *
5541  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5542  * hardware.
5543  *
5544  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5545  */
5546 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5547 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5548 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5549 				       size_t tailroom);
5550 
5551 /**
5552  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5553  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5554  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5555  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5556  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5557  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5558  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5559  *
5560  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5561  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5562  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5563  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5564  */
5565 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5566 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5567 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5568 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5569 
5570 /**
5571  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5572  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5573  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5574  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5575  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5576  *
5577  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5578  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5579  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5580  *
5581  * Return: The duration.
5582  */
5583 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5584 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5585 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5586 
5587 /**
5588  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5589  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5590  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5591  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5592  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5593  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5594  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5595  *
5596  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5597  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5598  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5599  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5600  */
5601 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5602 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5603 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5604 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5605 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5606 
5607 /**
5608  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5609  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5610  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5611  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5612  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5613  *
5614  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5615  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5616  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5617  *
5618  * Return: The duration.
5619  */
5620 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5621 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5622 				    size_t frame_len,
5623 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5624 
5625 /**
5626  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5627  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5628  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5629  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5630  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5631  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5632  *
5633  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5634  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5635  *
5636  * Return: The duration.
5637  */
5638 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5639 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5640 					enum nl80211_band band,
5641 					size_t frame_len,
5642 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5643 
5644 /**
5645  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5646  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5647  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5648  *
5649  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5650  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5651  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5652  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5653  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5654  *
5655  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5656  * frames are available.
5657  *
5658  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5659  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5660  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5661  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5662  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5663  * use common code for all beacons.
5664  */
5665 struct sk_buff *
5666 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5667 
5668 /**
5669  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5670  *
5671  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5672  *
5673  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5674  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5675  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5676  */
5677 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5678 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5679 
5680 /**
5681  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5682  *
5683  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5684  * from the given packet.
5685  *
5686  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5687  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5688  *	with this P1K
5689  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5690  */
5691 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5692 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5693 {
5694 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5695 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5696 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5697 
5698 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5699 }
5700 
5701 /**
5702  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5703  *
5704  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5705  * and transmitter address.
5706  *
5707  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5708  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5709  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5710  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5711  */
5712 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5713 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5714 
5715 /**
5716  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5717  *
5718  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5719  * in the packet.
5720  *
5721  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5722  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5723  *	encrypted with this key
5724  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5725  */
5726 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5727 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5728 
5729 /**
5730  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5731  *
5732  * @pos: start of crypto header
5733  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5734  * @pn: PN to add
5735  *
5736  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5737  * the packet payload)
5738  *
5739  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5740  * point to the crypto header)
5741  */
5742 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5743 
5744 /**
5745  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5746  *
5747  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5748  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5749  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5750  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5751  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5752  *
5753  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5754  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5755  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5756  *
5757  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5758  * can be done concurrently.
5759  */
5760 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5761 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5762 
5763 /**
5764  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5765  *
5766  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5767  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5768  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5769  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5770  * @seq: new sequence data
5771  *
5772  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5773  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5774  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5775  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5776  *
5777  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5778  * can be done concurrently.
5779  */
5780 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5781 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5782 
5783 /**
5784  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5785  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5786  *
5787  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5788  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5789  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5790  *
5791  * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5792  * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5793  */
5794 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5795 
5796 /**
5797  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5798  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5799  * @keyconf: new key data
5800  *
5801  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5802  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5803  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5804  *
5805  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5806  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5807  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5808  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5809  *
5810  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5811  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5812  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5813  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5814  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5815  * of the reconfiguration.
5816  *
5817  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5818  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5819  *
5820  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5821  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5822  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5823  * the key that's being replaced.
5824  */
5825 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5826 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5827 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5828 
5829 /**
5830  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5831  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5832  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5833  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5834  * @gfp: allocation flags
5835  */
5836 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5837 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5838 
5839 /**
5840  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5841  *
5842  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5843  * at the same time.
5844  *
5845  * @keyconf: the key in question
5846  */
5847 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5848 
5849 /**
5850  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5851  *
5852  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5853  * at the same time.
5854  *
5855  * @keyconf: the key in question
5856  */
5857 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5858 
5859 /**
5860  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5861  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5862  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5863  *
5864  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5865  */
5866 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5867 
5868 /**
5869  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5870  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5871  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5872  *
5873  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5874  */
5875 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5876 
5877 /**
5878  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5879  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5880  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5881  *
5882  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5883  *
5884  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5885  */
5886 
5887 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5888 
5889 /**
5890  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5891  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5892  *
5893  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5894  */
5895 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5896 
5897 /**
5898  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5899  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5900  *
5901  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5902  */
5903 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5904 
5905 /**
5906  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5907  *
5908  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5909  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5910  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5911  * any context, including hardirq context.
5912  *
5913  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5914  * @info: information about the completed scan
5915  */
5916 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5917 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5918 
5919 /**
5920  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5921  *
5922  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5923  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5924  *
5925  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5926  */
5927 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5928 
5929 /**
5930  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5931  *
5932  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5933  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5934  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5935  * while associating, for instance.
5936  *
5937  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5938  */
5939 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5940 
5941 /**
5942  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5943  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5944  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5945  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5946  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5947  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5948  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5949  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5950  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5951  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
5952  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
5953  *	for instance.
5954  */
5955 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5956 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
5957 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
5958 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
5959 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
5960 };
5961 
5962 /**
5963  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5964  *
5965  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5966  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5967  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5968  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5969  *
5970  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5971  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5972  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5973  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5974  */
5975 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5976 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5977 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5978 				  void *data);
5979 
5980 /**
5981  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5982  *
5983  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5984  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5985  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5986  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5987  * be used.
5988  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5989  *
5990  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5991  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5992  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5993  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5994  */
5995 static inline void
5996 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5997 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5998 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5999 				    void *data)
6000 {
6001 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6002 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6003 				     iterator, data);
6004 }
6005 
6006 /**
6007  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6008  *
6009  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6010  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6011  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6012  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6013  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6014  *
6015  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6016  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6017  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6018  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6019  */
6020 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6021 						u32 iter_flags,
6022 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6023 						    u8 *mac,
6024 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6025 						void *data);
6026 
6027 /**
6028  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6029  *
6030  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6031  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6032  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6033  *
6034  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6035  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6036  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6037  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6038  */
6039 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6040 					     u32 iter_flags,
6041 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6042 						u8 *mac,
6043 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6044 					     void *data);
6045 
6046 /**
6047  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6048  *
6049  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6050  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6051  * function for them.
6052  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6053  *
6054  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6055  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6056  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6057  */
6058 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6059 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6060 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6061 				       void *data);
6062 /**
6063  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6064  *
6065  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6066  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6067  *
6068  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6069  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6070  */
6071 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6072 
6073 /**
6074  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6075  *
6076  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6077  * workqueue.
6078  *
6079  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6080  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6081  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6082  */
6083 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6084 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6085 				  unsigned long delay);
6086 
6087 /**
6088  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6089  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6090  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6091  *
6092  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6093  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6094  * mac80211.
6095  *
6096  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6097  */
6098 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6099 					    u16 tid);
6100 
6101 /**
6102  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6103  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6104  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6105  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6106  *
6107  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6108  *
6109  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6110  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6111  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6112  */
6113 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6114 				  u16 timeout);
6115 
6116 /**
6117  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6118  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6119  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6120  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6121  *
6122  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6123  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6124  * from any context.
6125  */
6126 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6127 				      u16 tid);
6128 
6129 /**
6130  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6131  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6132  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6133  *
6134  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6135  *
6136  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6137  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6138  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6139  */
6140 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6141 
6142 /**
6143  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6144  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6145  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6146  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6147  *
6148  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6149  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6150  * can be called from any context.
6151  */
6152 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6153 				     u16 tid);
6154 
6155 /**
6156  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6157  *
6158  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6159  * @addr: station's address
6160  *
6161  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6162  *
6163  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6164  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6165  */
6166 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6167 					 const u8 *addr);
6168 
6169 /**
6170  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6171  *
6172  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6173  * @addr: remote station's address
6174  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6175  *
6176  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6177  *
6178  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6179  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6180  *
6181  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6182  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6183  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6184  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6185  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6186  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6187  *      is not reliable.
6188  *
6189  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6190  */
6191 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6192 					       const u8 *addr,
6193 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6194 
6195 /**
6196  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6197  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6198  * @addr: remote station's link address
6199  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6200  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6201  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6202  *
6203  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6204  */
6205 struct ieee80211_sta *
6206 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6207 				 const u8 *addr,
6208 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6209 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6210 
6211 /**
6212  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6213  * @hw: the hardware
6214  * @pubsta: the station
6215  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6216  *
6217  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6218  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6219  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6220  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6221  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6222  *
6223  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6224  * manner.
6225  *
6226  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6227  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6228  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6229  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6230  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6231  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6232  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6233  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6234  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6235  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6236  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6237  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6238  * woke up while blocked or not.
6239  */
6240 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6241 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6242 
6243 /**
6244  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6245  * @pubsta: the station
6246  *
6247  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6248  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6249  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6250  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6251  *
6252  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6253  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6254  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6255  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6256  *
6257  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6258  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6259  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6260  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6261  */
6262 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6263 
6264 /**
6265  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6266  * @pubsta: the station
6267  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6268  *
6269  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6270  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6271  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6272  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6273  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6274  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6275  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6276  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6277  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6278  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6279  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6280  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6281  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6282  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6283  */
6284 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6285 
6286 /**
6287  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6288  * @pubsta: the station
6289  *
6290  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6291  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6292  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6293  *
6294  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6295  * there is no need to call this function.
6296  */
6297 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6298 
6299 /**
6300  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6301  *
6302  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6303  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6304  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6305  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6306  *
6307  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6308  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6309  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6310  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6311  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6312  * attempts.
6313  *
6314  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6315  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6316  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6317  * them to 0.
6318  *
6319  * @pubsta: the station
6320  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6321  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6322  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6323  */
6324 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6325 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6326 
6327 /**
6328  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6329  *
6330  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6331  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6332  *
6333  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6334  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6335  */
6336 bool
6337 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6338 
6339 /**
6340  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6341  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6342  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6343  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6344  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6345  *
6346  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6347  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6348  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6349  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
6350  * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
6351  * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
6352  *
6353  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6354  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6355  * set_key callback.
6356  */
6357 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6358 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6359 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6360 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6361 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6362 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6363 				      void *data),
6364 			 void *iter_data);
6365 
6366 /**
6367  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6368  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6369  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6370  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6371  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6372  *
6373  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6374  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6375  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6376  * in removal process will be skipped.
6377  *
6378  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6379  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6380  */
6381 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6382 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6383 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6384 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6385 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6386 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6387 					  void *data),
6388 			     void *iter_data);
6389 
6390 /**
6391  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6392  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6393  * @iter: iterator function
6394  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6395  *
6396  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6397  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6398  * places while calling into the driver.
6399  *
6400  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6401  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6402  * removed.
6403  *
6404  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6405  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6406  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6407  * or not.
6408  */
6409 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6410 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6411 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6412 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6413 		     void *data),
6414 	void *iter_data);
6415 
6416 /**
6417  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6418  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6419  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6420  *
6421  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6422  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6423  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6424  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6425  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6426  * %NULL.
6427  *
6428  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6429  */
6430 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6431 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6432 
6433 /**
6434  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6435  *
6436  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6437  *
6438  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6439  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6440  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6441  */
6442 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6443 
6444 /**
6445  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6446  *
6447  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6448  *
6449  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6450  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6451  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6452  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6453  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6454  *
6455  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6456  * without connection recovery attempts.
6457  */
6458 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6459 
6460 /**
6461  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6462  *
6463  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6464  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6465  *
6466  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6467  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6468  */
6469 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6470 
6471 /**
6472  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6473  *
6474  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6475  *
6476  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6477  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6478  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6479  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6480  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6481  *
6482  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6483  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6484  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6485  * disconnect normally later.
6486  *
6487  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6488  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6489  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6490  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6491  */
6492 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6493 
6494 /**
6495  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6496  * hardware restart
6497  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6498  *
6499  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6500  * hardware restart.
6501  */
6502 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6503 
6504 /**
6505  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6506  *	rssi threshold triggered
6507  *
6508  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6509  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6510  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6511  * @gfp: context flags
6512  *
6513  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6514  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6515  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6516  */
6517 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6518 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6519 			       s32 rssi_level,
6520 			       gfp_t gfp);
6521 
6522 /**
6523  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6524  *
6525  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6526  * @gfp: context flags
6527  */
6528 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6529 
6530 /**
6531  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6532  *
6533  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6534  */
6535 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6536 
6537 /**
6538  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6539  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6540  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6541  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6542  *	false.
6543  *
6544  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6545  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6546  */
6547 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6548 			     unsigned int link_id);
6549 
6550 /**
6551  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6552  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6553  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6554  *
6555  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6556  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6557  * a deauth frame in this case.
6558  */
6559 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6560 					 bool block_tx);
6561 
6562 /**
6563  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6564  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6565  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6566  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6567  *
6568  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6569  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6570  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6571  */
6572 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6573 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6574 
6575 /**
6576  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6577  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6578  */
6579 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6580 
6581 /**
6582  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6583  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6584  */
6585 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6586 
6587 /**
6588  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6589  *
6590  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6591  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6592  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6593  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6594  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6595  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6596  *
6597  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6598  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6599  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6600  */
6601 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6602 				  const u8 *addr);
6603 
6604 /**
6605  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6606  * @pubsta: station struct
6607  * @tid: the session's TID
6608  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6609  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6610  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6611  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6612  *
6613  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6614  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6615  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6616  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6617  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6618  */
6619 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6620 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6621 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6622 
6623 /**
6624  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6625  *
6626  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6627  * buffer.
6628  *
6629  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6630  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6631  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6632  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6633  */
6634 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6635 
6636 /**
6637  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6638  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6639  * @addr: station mac address
6640  * @tid: the rx tid
6641  */
6642 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6643 				 unsigned int tid);
6644 
6645 /**
6646  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6647  *
6648  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6649  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6650  * reordering.
6651  *
6652  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6653  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6654  *
6655  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6656  * @addr: station mac address
6657  * @tid: the rx tid
6658  */
6659 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6660 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6661 {
6662 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6663 		return;
6664 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6665 }
6666 
6667 /**
6668  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6669  *
6670  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6671  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6672  * reordering.
6673  *
6674  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6675  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6676  *
6677  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6678  * @addr: station mac address
6679  * @tid: the rx tid
6680  */
6681 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6682 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6683 {
6684 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6685 		return;
6686 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6687 }
6688 
6689 /**
6690  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6691  *
6692  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6693  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6694  *
6695  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6696  *
6697  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6698  * @addr: station mac address
6699  * @tid: the rx tid
6700  */
6701 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6702 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6703 
6704 /* Rate control API */
6705 
6706 /**
6707  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6708  *
6709  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6710  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6711  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6712  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6713  *	to be filled in
6714  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6715  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6716  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6717  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6718  *	RTS threshold
6719  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6720  *	if the selected rate supports it
6721  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6722  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6723  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6724  */
6725 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6726 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6727 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6728 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6729 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6730 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6731 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6732 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6733 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6734 	bool bss;
6735 };
6736 
6737 /**
6738  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6739  */
6740 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6741 	/**
6742 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6743 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6744 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6745 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6746 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6747 	 */
6748 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6749 	/**
6750 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6751 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6752 	 */
6753 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6754 };
6755 
6756 struct rate_control_ops {
6757 	unsigned long capa;
6758 	const char *name;
6759 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6760 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6761 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6762 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6763 
6764 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6765 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6766 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6767 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6768 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6769 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6770 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6771 			    u32 changed);
6772 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6773 			 void *priv_sta);
6774 
6775 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6776 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6777 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6778 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6779 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6780 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6781 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6782 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6783 
6784 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6785 				struct dentry *dir);
6786 
6787 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6788 };
6789 
6790 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6791 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6792 				 int index)
6793 {
6794 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6795 }
6796 
6797 static inline s8
6798 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6799 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6800 {
6801 	int i;
6802 
6803 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6804 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6805 			return i;
6806 
6807 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6808 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6809 
6810 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6811 	return 0;
6812 }
6813 
6814 static inline
6815 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6816 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6817 {
6818 	unsigned int i;
6819 
6820 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6821 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6822 			return true;
6823 	return false;
6824 }
6825 
6826 /**
6827  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6828  *
6829  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6830  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6831  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6832  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6833  *
6834  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6835  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6836  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6837  */
6838 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6839 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6840 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6841 
6842 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6843 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6844 
6845 static inline bool
6846 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6847 {
6848 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6849 }
6850 
6851 static inline bool
6852 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6853 {
6854 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6855 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6856 }
6857 
6858 static inline bool
6859 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6860 {
6861 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6862 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6863 }
6864 
6865 static inline bool
6866 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6867 {
6868 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6869 }
6870 
6871 static inline bool
6872 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6873 {
6874 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6875 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6876 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6877 }
6878 
6879 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6880 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6881 {
6882 	if (p2p) {
6883 		switch (type) {
6884 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6885 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6886 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6887 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6888 		default:
6889 			break;
6890 		}
6891 	}
6892 	return type;
6893 }
6894 
6895 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6896 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6897 {
6898 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6899 }
6900 
6901 /**
6902  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6903  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6904  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6905  *
6906  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6907  */
6908 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
6909 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6910 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6911 {
6912 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6913 }
6914 
6915 /**
6916  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
6917  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
6918  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6919  *
6920  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
6921  */
6922 static inline __le16
6923 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6924 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6925 {
6926 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6927 }
6928 
6929 /**
6930  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
6931  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6932  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6933  *
6934  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
6935  */
6936 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
6937 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6938 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6939 {
6940 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6941 }
6942 
6943 /**
6944  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6945  *
6946  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6947  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
6948  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6949  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6950  *
6951  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6952  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6953  * matching GroupId management frame.
6954  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6955  */
6956 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6957 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6958 
6959 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6960 				   int rssi_min_thold,
6961 				   int rssi_max_thold);
6962 
6963 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6964 
6965 /**
6966  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6967  *
6968  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6969  *
6970  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6971  *
6972  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6973  * applicable.
6974  */
6975 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6976 
6977 /**
6978  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6979  * @vif: virtual interface
6980  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6981  * @gfp: allocation flags
6982  *
6983  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6984  */
6985 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6986 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6987 				    gfp_t gfp);
6988 
6989 /**
6990  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6991  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6992  * @vif: virtual interface
6993  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6994  * @band: the band to transmit on
6995  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6996  *
6997  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6998  */
6999 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7000 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7001 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7002 
7003 /**
7004  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7005  *				 of injected frames.
7006  *
7007  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7008  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7009  * of the skb before calling this function.
7010  *
7011  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7012  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7013  */
7014 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7015 				 struct net_device *dev);
7016 
7017 /**
7018  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7019  *
7020  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7021  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7022  *
7023  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7024  *
7025  * private:
7026  *
7027  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7028  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7029  */
7030 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7031 	u32 next_tsf;
7032 	bool has_next_tsf;
7033 
7034 	u8 absent;
7035 
7036 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7037 	struct {
7038 		u32 start;
7039 		u32 duration;
7040 		u32 interval;
7041 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7042 };
7043 
7044 /**
7045  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7046  *
7047  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7048  * @data: NoA tracking data
7049  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7050  *
7051  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7052  */
7053 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7054 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7055 
7056 /**
7057  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7058  *
7059  * @data: NoA tracking data
7060  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7061  */
7062 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7063 
7064 /**
7065  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7066  * @vif: virtual interface
7067  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7068  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7069  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7070  * @gfp: allocation flags
7071  *
7072  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7073  */
7074 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7075 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7076 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7077 
7078 /**
7079  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7080  *
7081  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7082  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7083  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7084  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7085  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7086  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7087  *
7088  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7089  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7090  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7091  *
7092  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7093  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7094  *
7095  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7096  */
7097 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7098 
7099 /**
7100  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7101  *
7102  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7103  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7104  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7105  *
7106  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7107  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7108  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7109  *
7110  * @sta: the station
7111  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7112  */
7113 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7114 
7115 /**
7116  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7117  *
7118  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7119  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7120  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7121  *
7122  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7123  *
7124  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7125  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7126  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7127  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7128  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7129  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7130  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7131  *
7132  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7133  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7134  */
7135 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7136 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7137 
7138 /**
7139  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7140  * (in process context)
7141  *
7142  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7143  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7144  *
7145  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7146  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7147  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7148  */
7149 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7150 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7151 {
7152 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7153 
7154 	local_bh_disable();
7155 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7156 	local_bh_enable();
7157 
7158 	return skb;
7159 }
7160 
7161 /**
7162  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7163  *
7164  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7165  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7166  *
7167  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7168  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7169  */
7170 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7171 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7172 
7173 /**
7174  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7175  *
7176  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7177  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7178  *
7179  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7180  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7181  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7182  */
7183 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7184 
7185 /**
7186  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7187  *
7188  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7189  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7190  *
7191  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7192  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7193  */
7194 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7195 
7196 /* (deprecated) */
7197 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7198 {
7199 }
7200 
7201 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7202 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7203 
7204 /**
7205  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7206  *
7207  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7208  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7209  *
7210  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7211  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7212  *
7213  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7214  * this TXQ internally.
7215  */
7216 static inline void
7217 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7218 {
7219 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7220 }
7221 
7222 /**
7223  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7224  *
7225  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7226  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7227  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7228  *
7229  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7230  * internally.
7231  */
7232 static inline void
7233 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7234 		     bool force)
7235 {
7236 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7237 }
7238 
7239 /**
7240  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7241  *
7242  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7243  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7244  * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
7245  * next_txq().
7246  *
7247  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7248  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7249  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7250  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7251  * again.
7252  *
7253  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7254  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7255  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7256  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7257  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7258  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7259  *
7260  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7261  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7262  */
7263 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7264 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7265 
7266 /**
7267  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7268  *
7269  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7270  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7271  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7272  *
7273  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7274  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7275  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7276  */
7277 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7278 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7279 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7280 
7281 /**
7282  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7283  *
7284  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7285  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7286  *
7287  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7288  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7289  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7290  * @gfp: allocation flags
7291  */
7292 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7293 				   u8 inst_id,
7294 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7295 				   gfp_t gfp);
7296 
7297 /**
7298  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7299  *
7300  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7301  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7302  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7303  *
7304  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7305  * @match: match event information
7306  * @gfp: allocation flags
7307  */
7308 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7309 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7310 			      gfp_t gfp);
7311 
7312 /**
7313  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7314  *
7315  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7316  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7317  *
7318  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7319  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7320  *          information.
7321  * @len: frame length in bytes
7322  */
7323 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7324 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7325 			      int len);
7326 
7327 /**
7328  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7329  *
7330  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7331  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7332  *
7333  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7334  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7335  * @len: frame length in bytes
7336  */
7337 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7338 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7339 			      int len);
7340 /**
7341  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7342  *
7343  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7344  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7345  * hardware or firmware.
7346  *
7347  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7348  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7349  */
7350 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7351 
7352 /**
7353  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7354  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7355  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7356  *
7357  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7358  *
7359  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7360  */
7361 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7362 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7363 
7364 /**
7365  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7366  *	probe response template.
7367  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7368  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7369  *
7370  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7371  *
7372  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7373  */
7374 struct sk_buff *
7375 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7376 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7377 
7378 /**
7379  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7380  * collision.
7381  *
7382  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7383  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7384  *	aware of.
7385  * @gfp: allocation flags
7386  */
7387 void
7388 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7389 				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7390 
7391 /**
7392  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7393  *
7394  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7395  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7396  *
7397  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7398  */
7399 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7400 {
7401 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7402 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7403 
7404 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7405 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7406 }
7407 
7408 /**
7409  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7410  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7411  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7412  *
7413  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7414  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7415  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7416  *
7417  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7418  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7419  * a sequence of calls like
7420  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7421  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7422  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7423  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7424  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7425  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7426  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7427  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7428  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7429  *
7430  * Note: This function acquires some mac80211 locks and must not
7431  *	 be called with any driver locks held that could cause a
7432  *	 lock dependency inversion. Best call it without locks.
7433  */
7434 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7435 
7436 /**
7437  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7438  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7439  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7440  *
7441  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7442  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7443  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7444  * completed after it returns.
7445  */
7446 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7447 				      u16 active_links);
7448 
7449 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7450